blob: 38287e4929559566213d50b77b48395c032d0c47 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000060 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
61 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000062
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000064 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
65 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
66 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
67 else
68 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000069 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000070 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
71 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000072
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000073 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000074 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
76 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
77 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
78 return true;
79 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000080 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000081
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000082 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000083}
84
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000085/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000087/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
88///
89void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000090 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000091 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000094
95 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
96 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000097 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
98 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000099
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000100 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
101 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000102 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000103 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
104 int isMethod = 0;
105 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
106 // skip over named parameters.
107 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
108 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
109 if (nullPos)
110 --nullPos;
111 else
112 ++i;
113 }
114 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
115 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000116 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000117 // skip over named parameters.
118 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
119 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
120 if (nullPos)
121 --nullPos;
122 else
123 ++i;
124 }
125 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000126 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000127 // block or function pointer call.
128 QualType Ty = V->getType();
129 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000130 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000131 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
132 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000133 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
134 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
135 unsigned k;
136 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
137 if (nullPos)
138 --nullPos;
139 else
140 ++i;
141 }
142 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
143 }
144 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
145 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000146 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000147 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 return;
150
151 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000152 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000153 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000154 return;
155 }
156 int sentinel = i;
157 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
158 --sentinelPos;
159 ++i;
160 }
161 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
162 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000163 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000164 return;
165 }
166 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
167 ++i;
168 ++sentinel;
169 }
170 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
172 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
173 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000174 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000175 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
176 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
177 return;
178
179 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
180 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
181
182 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
183 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000184}
185
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000186SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
187 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
188 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
189}
190
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
192// Standard Promotions and Conversions
193//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
194
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000195/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
196void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
197 QualType Ty = E->getType();
198 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
199
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000200 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000201 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000202 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000203 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
204 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
205 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
206 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
207 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
208 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
209 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000210 //
211 // C++ 4.2p1:
212 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
213 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
214 //
215 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
216 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000217 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000218 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000219 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000220}
221
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000224
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000225 QualType Ty = E->getType();
226 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
227 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
228 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
229 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
230 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
231 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
232 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
233 // rvalue is T
234 //
235 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000236 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
237 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000238 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000239 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000240 }
241}
242
243
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000244/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
247/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
248/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
249Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
250 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
251 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000252
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000253 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
254 //
255 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
256 // unsigned int may be used:
257 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
258 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
259 // and unsigned int.
260 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
261 //
262 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
263 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
264 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
265 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000266 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
267 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000268 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000269 return Expr;
270 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000272 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000273 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000274 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000275 }
276
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000277 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000278 return Expr;
279}
280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000282/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000283/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
284void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
285 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
286 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000287
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000288 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000289 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
290 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000291 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000292
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000293 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
294}
295
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000296/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
297/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
298/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
299/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
301 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000302 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000303
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000304 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
305 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
306 // etc.
307 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
308 return false;
309
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000310 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
312 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
313 << Expr->getType() << CT))
314 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000315
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000316 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000317 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000318 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
319 << Expr->getType() << CT))
320 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000321
322 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000323}
324
325
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000326/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
327/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000328/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000329/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
330/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
331/// GCC.
332QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
333 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000334 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000335 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000336
337 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000340 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000341 QualType lhs =
342 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000343 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000344 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000345
346 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
347 if (lhs == rhs)
348 return lhs;
349
350 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
351 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
352 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
353 return lhs;
354
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000355 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000356 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000357 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
358 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000359 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000360 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
361 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
362
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000363 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000364 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000365 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
366 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000367 return destType;
368}
369
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000370//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
371// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
372//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
373
374
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
377/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
378/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
379/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000381ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000382Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000383 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
384
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000385 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000386 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000387 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000388
389 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
390 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
391 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000393 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000394 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000395 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000396
397 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000398 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000399 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000400
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000401 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
402 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
403 // strings.
404 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000405 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000406 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000407
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000408 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000409 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
410 Literal.GetStringLength(),
411 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
412 &StringTokLocs[0],
413 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000414}
415
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000416/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
417/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
418/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
419/// for values inside the block or for globals).
420///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000421/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000422/// up-to-date.
423///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000424static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000425 ValueDecl *VD) {
426 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
427 // we wanted to.
428 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
429 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000430
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000431 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
432 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
433 return false;
434
435 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
436 // snapshot it.
437 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
438 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000439 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
440 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000441
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
443 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
444
445 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
446 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
447 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
448 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000449 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
450 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000451
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000452 if (!NextBlock)
453 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000454
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000455 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
456 // having a reference outside it.
457 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
458 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000460 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
461 // a snapshot as well.
462 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
463 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000464
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000465 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000466}
467
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000468
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000469ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000470Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000471 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000472 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
473 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
474}
475
476/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000477ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
479 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
480 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000481 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000482 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000484 << D->getDeclName();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000487
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000488 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
490 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
491 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000492 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000493 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
495 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000496 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
497 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000498 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000500 << D->getIdentifier();
501 return ExprError();
502 }
503 }
504 }
505 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000506
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000507 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000508
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000509 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
510 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
511 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000512 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000513}
514
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000515/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
516/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
517/// actual member.
518///
519/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
520/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
521/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
522/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
523/// we found.
524///
525/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
526/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
527/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
528VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
529 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000530 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
531 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
532 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
533
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000535 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
536 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
537 do {
538 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000539 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000540 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000542 else {
543 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
544 break;
545 }
546 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000547 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000549
550 return BaseObject;
551}
552
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000553ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000554Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
555 FieldDecl *Field,
556 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
557 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
558 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000559 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000560 AnonFields);
561
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
563 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
564 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
565 // found via name lookup.
566 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 if (BaseObject) {
569 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
570 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000571 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000572 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000573 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000574 BaseQuals
575 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000576 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
577 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
578 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
579 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
580 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000581 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000582 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
583 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
584 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000585 BaseQuals
586 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000587 } else {
588 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
589 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
590 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000591 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
592 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000593 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 = Context.getTagDeclType(
596 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
597 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000598 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000599 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
600 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
601 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000602 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000603 MD->getThisType(Context),
604 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
606 }
607 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000608 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
609 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000610 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000611 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000612 }
613
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000614 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000615 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
616 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 }
618
619 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
620 // anonymous struct/union.
621 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000622 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
624 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
625 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
626 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000627 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
628 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
629
630 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
631 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
632 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
633 ResultQuals.removeConst();
634
635 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
636 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
637
638 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
639 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
640
641 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
642 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
643 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
644
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000645 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000646 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000647 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000648 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
649 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000650 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000651 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652 }
653
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000654 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000655}
656
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000657/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000658/// possibly a list of template arguments.
659///
660/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
661/// DecomposeTemplateName.
662///
663/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
664/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
665/// some way.
666static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
667 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
668 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000669 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000670 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
671 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
672 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
673 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
674
675 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
676 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
677 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
678 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
679 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
680
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000681 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
683 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
685 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000686 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 TemplateArgs = 0;
688 }
689}
690
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
692/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
693/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000695 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
696 return false;
697
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000698 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
699 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
700 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
701 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
702 if (!BaseRT) return false;
703
704 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000705 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
707 return false;
708 }
709
710 return true;
711}
712
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000713/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
714/// the prospective base classes.
715static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
716 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
717 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719 return false;
720
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000721 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000722 if (!RD) return false;
723 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
724
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
726 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
727 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
728 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
729 if (!BaseRT) return false;
730
731 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000732 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000738
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739enum IMAKind {
740 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
741 IMA_Static,
742
743 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
744 IMA_Mixed,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
748 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
749
750 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
751 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
752 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
753
754 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
755 IMA_Instance,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
758 IMA_Unresolved,
759
760 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
761 /// context is not an instance method.
762 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
763
764 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
765 /// non-class context.
766 IMA_AnonymousMember,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
769 /// context is not an instance method.
770 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
771
772 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
773 /// class.
774 IMA_Error_Unrelated
775};
776
777/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
778/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
779/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
780/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
781/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
782/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
783static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
784 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000785 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000786
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000787 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000788 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000789 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
790 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000791
792 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
793 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
794
795 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
796 bool hasNonInstance = false;
797 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
798 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000799 NamedDecl *D = *I;
800 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000801 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
802
803 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
804 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
805 // that's a special case.
806 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
807 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
808 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
809 }
810 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
811 }
812 else
813 hasNonInstance = true;
814 }
815
816 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
817 // member reference.
818 if (Classes.empty())
819 return IMA_Static;
820
821 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
822 // an implicit member reference.
823 if (isStaticContext)
824 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
825
826 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
827 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
828 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
829 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000830 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000831 Classes))
832 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
833
834 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
835}
836
837/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
838static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
839 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
840 const LookupResult &R) {
841 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
842 SourceRange Range(Loc);
843 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
844
845 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
846 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
847 if (MD->isStatic()) {
848 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
850 << Range << R.getLookupName();
851 return;
852 }
853 }
854
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
856 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
857 return;
858 }
859
860 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000861}
862
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000863/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
864///
865/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000866bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
867 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
869
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000870 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000871 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
873 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000874 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000876 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
877 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000879 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
880 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
881 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
882 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000883 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000884 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
886 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
887
888 if (!R.empty()) {
889 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
890 R.suppressDiagnostics();
891
892 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
893 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
894 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
895 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
896
897 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
898 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
899 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
902 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000903 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000904 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000905 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000906 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
907 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
908 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
909 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
910 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
911 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
912 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
913 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
914 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
915 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
916 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
917 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
918 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
919 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000921 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
922 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
923 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000924 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000925 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000926 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000927 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928
929 // Do we really want to note all of these?
930 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
931 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
932
933 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
934 return false;
935 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000936
937 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000938 }
939 }
940
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000941 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000942 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000943 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000944 if (!R.empty()) {
945 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 if (SS.isEmpty())
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
948 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
949 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
950 else
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
952 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
953 << SS.getRange()
954 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
955 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
956 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
957 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
958 << ND->getDeclName();
959
960 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
961 return false;
962 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000963
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
965 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
966 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
967 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
968 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
969 // to recover well anyway.
970 if (SS.isEmpty())
971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange();
976
977 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
978 return true;
979 }
980 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000985 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
988 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 return true;
990 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000991 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000992 }
993
994 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
995 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
996 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
998 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
999 << SS.getRange();
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001003 // Give up, we can't recover.
1004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1005 return true;
1006}
1007
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001008static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001009 IdentifierInfo *II,
1010 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001011 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1012 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1013 if (!IDecl)
1014 return 0;
1015 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1016 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1017 return 0;
1018 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1019 if (!property)
1020 return 0;
1021 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1022 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1023 return 0;
1024 return property;
1025}
1026
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001027static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II,
1030 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1031 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001032 bool LookForIvars;
1033 if (Lookup.empty())
1034 LookForIvars = true;
1035 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1036 LookForIvars = false;
1037 else
1038 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1039 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1040 if (!LookForIvars)
1041 return 0;
1042
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001043 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1044 if (!IDecl)
1045 return 0;
1046 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001047 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1048 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001049 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1050 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1051 if (!property)
1052 return 0;
1053 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1054 DynamicImplSeen =
1055 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1056 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001057 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1058 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001059 NameLoc,
1060 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1061 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1062 (Expr *)0, true);
1063 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1064 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1065 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1066 return Ivar;
1067 }
1068 return 0;
1069}
1070
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001071ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001072 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1073 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1074 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1075 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1077 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1078
1079 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001080 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001081
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001082 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083
1084 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001088
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001089 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001090 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001091 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001092
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1094 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001095 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1096 // (note: handled after lookup)
1097 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1098 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1099 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001100 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1101 // names a dependent type.
1102 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1103 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001104 bool DependentID = false;
1105 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1106 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1107 DependentID = true;
1108 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1109 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1110 if (DC) {
1111 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1112 return ExprError();
1113 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1114 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1115 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1116 } else {
1117 DependentID = true;
1118 }
1119 }
1120
1121 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001122 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 TemplateArgs);
1124 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001125 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001127 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001128 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001129 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1130 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1131 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1132 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1133 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001134 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1135 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1136 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001138 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001140
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1142 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001143 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001144 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001145 if (E.isInvalid())
1146 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001147
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1149 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001150 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1151 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001152 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001153 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1154 isAddressOfOperand);
1155 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001156 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1157 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001158 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001159 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001160
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001161 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1162 return ExprError();
1163
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001164 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1165 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001167
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001169 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1171 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1172 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1173 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1174 }
1175
1176 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1177 // call, diagnose the problem.
1178 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001179 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001180 return ExprError();
1181
1182 assert(!R.empty() &&
1183 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184
1185 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1186 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001187 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001188 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1189 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001190 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001191 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1192 return move(E);
1193 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001194 }
1195 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001196
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001197 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1198 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1199
1200 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001201 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001202 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1203 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001204 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1205 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1206 if (Property) {
1207 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1208 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001209 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001210 }
1211 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001212 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001213 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1214 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1215 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1216 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1217 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1218 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001219 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001220 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001221
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001222 QualType T = Func->getType();
1223 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001224 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001225 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1226 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001227 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001228 }
1229 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001230
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001231 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001232 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1233 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1234 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1235 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1236 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1237 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1238 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1239 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001240 //
1241 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1242 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1243 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1244 // non-static member function:
1245 //
1246 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1247 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1248 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1249 // member function call.
1250 //
1251 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1252 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1253 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1254 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001255 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001256 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1257 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1258 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1259 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1260 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1261 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1262 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001263 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1264 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001265 else
1266 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1267
1268 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001269 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001270 }
1271
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 if (TemplateArgs)
1273 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001274
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1276}
1277
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001278/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001279ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001280Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1281 LookupResult &R,
1282 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1283 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1284 case IMA_Instance:
1285 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1286
1287 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1288 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1289 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1290 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1291
1292 case IMA_Mixed:
1293 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1294 case IMA_Unresolved:
1295 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1296
1297 case IMA_Static:
1298 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1299 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1300 if (TemplateArgs)
1301 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1302 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1303
1304 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1305 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1306 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1307 return ExprError();
1308 }
1309
1310 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1311 return ExprError();
1312}
1313
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001314/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1315/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1316/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1317/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001318ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001319Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001320 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001322 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001323 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001325 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001326 return ExprError();
1327
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001328 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1330
1331 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1332 return ExprError();
1333
1334 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001335 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1336 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001337 return ExprError();
1338 }
1339
1340 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1341}
1342
1343/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1344/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1345/// additional lookup.
1346///
1347/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1348/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1349///
1350/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001351ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001352Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001353 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001355 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001356
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001357 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1358 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1359 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1360 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1361 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1362
1363 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1364 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1365 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001366 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367
1368 bool LookForIvars;
1369 if (Lookup.empty())
1370 LookForIvars = true;
1371 else if (IsClassMethod)
1372 LookForIvars = false;
1373 else
1374 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1375 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001378 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1380 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1381 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1382 if (IsClassMethod)
1383 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1384 << IV->getDeclName());
1385
1386 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1387 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1388 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1389 return ExprError();
1390
1391 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1392 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1393 return ExprError();
1394
1395 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1396 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1397 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1398 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1399
1400 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1401 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1402 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1403 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001404 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001405 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001406 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001407 SelfName, false, false);
1408 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1409 return ExprError();
1410
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001411 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1412 return Owned(new (Context)
1413 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1414 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1415 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001416 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001417 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001419 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1420 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1421 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1422 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1423 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1424 }
1425 }
1426
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001427 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1428 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1429 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1430 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1431 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1432 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1433 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1434 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1435 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1436 }
1437 }
1438 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001439 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1440 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001441}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001442
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001443/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1444///
1445/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1446///
1447/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1448/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1449/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1450/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1451///
1452/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1453/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1454/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1455/// the class declaring the member.
1456///
1457/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1458/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1459/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001460bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001461Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1462 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001463 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001464 NamedDecl *Member) {
1465 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1466 if (!RD)
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001469 QualType DestRecordType;
1470 QualType DestType;
1471 QualType FromRecordType;
1472 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1473 bool PointerConversions = false;
1474 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1475 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001476
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001477 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1478 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1479 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1480 PointerConversions = true;
1481 } else {
1482 DestType = DestRecordType;
1483 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001484 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1486 if (Method->isStatic())
1487 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001488
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1490 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1493 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1494 PointerConversions = true;
1495 } else {
1496 FromRecordType = FromType;
1497 DestType = DestRecordType;
1498 }
1499 } else {
1500 // No conversion necessary.
1501 return false;
1502 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1505 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001506
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1508 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1509 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001511 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1512 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1513
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001514 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001515
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001517 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001518 // class name.
1519 //
1520 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1521 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1522 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1523 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1524 //
1525 // class Base { public: int x; };
1526 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1527 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1528 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1529 //
1530 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1531 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1532 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1533 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001535 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1536 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1537 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1538
1539 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1540
1541 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1542 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1543 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1544 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001545 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001546 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001547 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 return true;
1549
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001552 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1553 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001554
1555 FromType = QType;
1556 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1557
1558 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1559 // we're done.
1560 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1561 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 }
1563 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001564
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001565 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001566
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001567 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1568 // down to the using declaration's type.
1569 //
1570 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1571 // class ever has member declarations.
1572 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1573 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1574 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1575 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1576
1577 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1578 // conversion is non-trivial.
1579 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1580 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001581 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001582 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001583 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001585
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001586 QualType UType = URecordType;
1587 if (PointerConversions)
1588 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001589 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001590 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001591 FromType = UType;
1592 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1593 }
1594
1595 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1596 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1597 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001598 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001599
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001600 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001601 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1602 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001603 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001604 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001605
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001606 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001607 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001608 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001609}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001610
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001611/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001612static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001613 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001614 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001615 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1616 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1618 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1619 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001620 if (SS.isSet()) {
1621 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1622 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001624
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001625 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001626 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1627 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001628}
1629
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001630/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1631/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1632/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1633/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001634ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001635Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1636 LookupResult &R,
1637 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1638 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1640
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001641 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001642
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001643 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1644 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001645 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001646 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001647 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001648 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001650
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001651 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1652 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001653 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1654 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001655 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1656 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001657 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1658 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1659 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1660 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001661 }
1662
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001663 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001664 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1665 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001666 SS,
1667 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1668 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001669}
1670
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 const LookupResult &R,
1673 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1675 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1676 return false;
1677
1678 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 return false;
1681
1682 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001683 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684 return false;
1685
1686 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1687 // normal lookup:
1688 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1689 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1690
1691 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1692 // -- a declaration of a class member
1693 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1694 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001695 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696 return false;
1697
1698 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1699 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1700 // using-declaration
1701 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1702 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1703 // turn off ADL anyway).
1704 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1705 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1706 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1707 return false;
1708
1709 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1710 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1711 // template
1712 // And also for builtin functions.
1713 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1714 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1715
1716 // But also builtin functions.
1717 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1718 return false;
1719 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1720 return false;
1721 }
1722
1723 return true;
1724}
1725
1726
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1728/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1729/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1730/// will in fact be used.
1731static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1732 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1733 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1734 return true;
1735 }
1736
1737 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1738 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1739 return true;
1740 }
1741
1742 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1743 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1744 return true;
1745 }
1746
1747 return false;
1748}
1749
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001750ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001751Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001752 LookupResult &R,
1753 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001754 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1755 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001756 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001757 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1758 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001759
1760 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1761 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1762 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001763 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1764 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001765 return ExprError();
1766
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001767 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1768 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1769 // we've picked a target.
1770 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1771
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001772 bool Dependent
1773 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001774 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001775 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001776 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001777 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001778 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1779 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001780
1781 return Owned(ULE);
1782}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001783
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001784
1785/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001786ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001787Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001788 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1789 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001790 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001791 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1792 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001793
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001794 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001795 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1796 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001797
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001798 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1799 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1800 // a template argument list.
1801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1802 << Template << SS.getRange();
1803 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1804 return ExprError();
1805 }
1806
1807 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1808 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1809 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001810 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001811 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001812 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001813 return ExprError();
1814 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001816 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1817 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1818 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1819 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001821 return ExprError();
1822
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001823 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1824 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001825 return ExprError();
1826
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001827 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1828 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1829 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1830 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001831 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001832 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1833 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1834 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001835 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001836 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001837 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1838 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1840 return ExprError();
1841 }
1842
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001843 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001844 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1845 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1846 return ExprError();
1847 }
1848
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001849 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001850 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001851 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001852 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001853 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001854 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1855 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001856 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001858 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001859 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001860 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1861 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001862 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1864 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1865 Expr *E = new (Context)
1866 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1867 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001868
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001869 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001870 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001871 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001872 SourceLocation(),
1873 Owned(E));
1874 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001875 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001876 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1877 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1878 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001879 }
1880 }
1881 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001882 }
1883 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1884 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001885
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001886 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1887 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001888}
1889
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001890ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001891 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001892 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001893
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001894 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001895 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001896 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1897 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1898 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001899 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001900
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001901 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1902 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001904 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001905 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1906 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001907 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001908 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001909 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001910 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001911
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001912 QualType ResTy;
1913 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1914 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1915 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001916 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001917
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001918 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001919 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001920 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1921 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001922 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001923}
1924
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001925ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001926 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001927 bool Invalid = false;
1928 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1929 if (Invalid)
1930 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001932 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1933 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001934 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001936
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001937 QualType Ty;
1938 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1939 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1940 else if (Literal.isWide())
1941 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001942 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1943 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001944 else
1945 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001946
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001947 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1948 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001949 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001950}
1951
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001952ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001953 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001954 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1955 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001956 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001957 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001958 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001959 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001960 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001961
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001962 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001963 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1964 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001965 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001967 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001968 bool Invalid = false;
1969 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1970 if (Invalid)
1971 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001973 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001974 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1975 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976 return ExprError();
1977
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001978 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001980 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001981 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001982 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001983 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001984 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001985 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001986 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001987 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001988
1989 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1990
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001991 using llvm::APFloat;
1992 APFloat Val(Format);
1993
1994 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001995
1996 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1997 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1998 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1999 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002000 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002001 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002002 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002003 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002004 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2005 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002006 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002007 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2008 }
2009
2010 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2011 << Ty
2012 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2013 }
2014
2015 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002016 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002017
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002018 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002020 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002021 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002022
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002023 // long long is a C99 feature.
2024 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002025 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002026 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2027
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002028 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002029 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002030
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002031 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2032 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2033 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002034 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2035 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002036 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002037 } else {
2038 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2039 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002040
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002041 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2042 // be an unsigned int.
2043 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2044
2045 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002047 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2048 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002049 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002050
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002051 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2052 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2053 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2054 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002055 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002056 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002058 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002059 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002060 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002061
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002062 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002064 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002066 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2067 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2068 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2069 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002070 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002071 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002072 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002074 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002075 }
2076
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002077 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002079 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002080
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002081 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2082 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2083 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2084 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002085 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002086 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002088 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 }
2090 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002091
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002092 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2093 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002094 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002095 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002096 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002098 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002099
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2101 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002102 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002103 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002104 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002105
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002106 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2107 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002108 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002109 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002110
2111 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002112}
2113
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002114ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002115 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002116 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002117 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002118}
2119
2120/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2121/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002122bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002123 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2124 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2125 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002126 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2127 return false;
2128
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002129 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2130 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2131 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2132 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2133 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2134 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2135
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002136 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002137 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002138 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002139 if (isSizeof)
2140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2141 return false;
2142 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002144 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002145 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2147 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002148 return false;
2149 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002150
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002152 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2153 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002154 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002156 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002157 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002159 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2160 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002161 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002163 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2164 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2165 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2166 return true;
2167 }
2168
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002169 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002170}
2171
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002172bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2173 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2174 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002175
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002176 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002177 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2178 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002179
2180 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2181 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2182 return false;
2183
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002184 if (E->getBitField()) {
2185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2186 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002187 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002188
2189 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2190 // bit-field.
2191 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002192 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002193 return false;
2194
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002195 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2196}
2197
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002198/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002199ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002201 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002202 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002203 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002204 return ExprError();
2205
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002206 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002207
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002208 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2209 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2210 return ExprError();
2211
2212 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002213 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002214 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2215 R.getEnd()));
2216}
2217
2218/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2219/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002220ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002221Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002222 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2223 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2224 bool isInvalid = false;
2225 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2226 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2227 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2228 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002229 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002230 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2231 isInvalid = true;
2232 } else {
2233 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2234 }
2235
2236 if (isInvalid)
2237 return ExprError();
2238
2239 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2240 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2241 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2242 R.getEnd()));
2243}
2244
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002245/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2246/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2247/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002248ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002249Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2250 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002251 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002252 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002253
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002254 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002255 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002256 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002257 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002258 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002259
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002260 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002261 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002262 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2263
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002264 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002265}
2266
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002267QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002268 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2269 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002270
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002271 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002272 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002273 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002274
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002275 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2276 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2277 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002278
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002279 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002280 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2281 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002282 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002283}
2284
2285
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002286
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002287ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002288Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002289 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002290 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002291 switch (Kind) {
2292 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002293 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2294 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002295 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002296
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002297 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002298}
2299
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002300ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002301Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2302 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002303 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002304 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002305 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2306 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002307
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002308 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002309
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002310 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002311 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002312 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2313 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2314 }
2315
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002317 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002318 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2319 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2320 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002321 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002322 }
2323
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002324 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002325}
2326
2327
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002328ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002329Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2330 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2331 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2332 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002333
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002334 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002335 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2336 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2337 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002338
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002339 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002340
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002341 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002342 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002343 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002344 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002345 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2346 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002347 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2348 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2349 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2350 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002351 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002352 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2353 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002354 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002355 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002356 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002357 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2358 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002359 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002360 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002361 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002362 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2363 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2364 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002365 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002366 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002367 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2368 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2369 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2370 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002371 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002372 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002373 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002374
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002375 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2376 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002377 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2378 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002379 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002380 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2381 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2382 // force the promotion here.
2383 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2384 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002385 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002386 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002387 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2388
2389 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2390 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002391 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002392 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2393 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2394 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2395 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002396 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002397 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002398 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2399
2400 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2401 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002402 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002403 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002404 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2405 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002406 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002407 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002408 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002409 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2410 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002411
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002412 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002413 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2414 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002415 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2416
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002417 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002418 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2419 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002420 // incomplete types are not object types.
2421 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2422 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2423 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2424 return ExprError();
2425 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002426
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002427 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2428 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2429 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2430 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2431 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002432 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002433 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2434 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002435 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002436
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002437 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002438 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002439 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2440 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2441 return ExprError();
2442 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002443
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002444 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002445 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002446}
2447
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002448QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002449CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002450 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002451 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002452 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2453 // see FIXME there.
2454 //
2455 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2456 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002457 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002458
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002459 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002460 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002461
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002462 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002463 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2464 // to be selected.
2465 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002466
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002467 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2468 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002469 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002470
2471 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2472 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002473 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002474 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2475 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002476 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002477 do
2478 compStr++;
2479 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002480 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002481 do
2482 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002483 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002484 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002485
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002486 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002487 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2488 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002489 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002490 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002491 return QualType();
2492 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002493
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002494 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2495 // operates on.
2496 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002497 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002498
2499 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002500 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002501
2502 while (*compStr) {
2503 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2504 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2505 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2506 return QualType();
2507 }
2508 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002509 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002510
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002511 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002512 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002513 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002514 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002515 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002516 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002517 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002518 if (HexSwizzle)
2519 CompSize--;
2520
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002521 if (CompSize == 1)
2522 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002523
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002524 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002525 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002526 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2527 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2528 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2529 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002530 }
2531 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002532}
2533
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002534static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002535 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002536 const Selector &Sel,
2537 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002538
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002539 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002540 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002541 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002542 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002543
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002544 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2545 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002546 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002547 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002548 return D;
2549 }
2550 return 0;
2551}
2552
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002553static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002554 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002555 const Selector &Sel,
2556 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002557 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2558 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002559 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002560 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002561 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002562 GDecl = PD;
2563 break;
2564 }
2565 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002566 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002567 GDecl = OMD;
2568 break;
2569 }
2570 }
2571 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002572 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002573 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2574 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002575 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002576 if (GDecl)
2577 return GDecl;
2578 }
2579 }
2580 return GDecl;
2581}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002582
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002583ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002584Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002585 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002586 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2587 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002588 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002590 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2591 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2592 //
2593 // T* t;
2594 // t.f;
2595 //
2596 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2597 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2598 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2599 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002600 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002601 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2602 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002603 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002604 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002605 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606 return ExprError();
2607 }
2608 }
2609
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002610 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2611 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002612 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002613
2614 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2615 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002616 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002617 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002618 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002619 SS.getRange(),
2620 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002621 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002622}
2623
2624/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2625/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2626/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2627static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2628 Expr *BaseExpr,
2629 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002630 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002631 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002632 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2633 // diagnostics.
2634 if (!BaseExpr)
2635 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002637 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2638 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639}
2640
2641// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2642// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2643// type. The restriction here is:
2644//
2645// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2646// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2647// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2648//
2649// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2650// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2651// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2652// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2653bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2654 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002655 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002656 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002657 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2658 if (!BaseRT) {
2659 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2660 // dependent.
2661 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2662 return false;
2663 }
2664 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002665
2666 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2668 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002669 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002673 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2674 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2675 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002676
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002677 if (!DC->isRecord())
2678 continue;
2679
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002681 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002682
2683 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2684 return false;
2685 }
2686
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002687 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 return true;
2689}
2690
2691static bool
2692LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2693 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002694 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2695 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002696 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2697 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002698 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002699 << BaseRange))
2700 return true;
2701
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002702 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2703 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2704 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2705
2706 bool MOUS;
2707 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2708 return false;
2709 }
2710
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2712 if (SS.isSet()) {
2713 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2714 // nested-name-specifier.
2715 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2716
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002717 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002718 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2719 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2720 return true;
2721 }
2722
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002724
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002725 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2726 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2727 << DC << SS.getRange();
2728 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002729 }
2730 }
2731
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002732 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2733 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002734
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002735 if (!R.empty())
2736 return false;
2737
2738 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2739 // for typos.
2740 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002741 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002742 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002743 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2744 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2745 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002746 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2747 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002748 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2749 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2750 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002751 return false;
2752 } else {
2753 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002754 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002755 }
2756
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002757 return false;
2758}
2759
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002760ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002761Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002762 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002763 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002765 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002766 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002767 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2768 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002769 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2771 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002772 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002773
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002774 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002776 // Implicit member accesses.
2777 if (!Base) {
2778 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2779 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2780 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2781 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002782 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002783 return ExprError();
2784
2785 // Explicit member accesses.
2786 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002787 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002788 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002789 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002790
2791 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2792 Owned(Base);
2793 return ExprError();
2794 }
2795
2796 if (Result.get())
2797 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002798
2799 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2800 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 }
2802
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002803 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002804 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2805 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806}
2807
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002808ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002809Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002810 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2811 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002812 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002813 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002814 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2815 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002816 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002817 if (IsArrow) {
2818 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2819 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2820 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002821 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002823 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002824 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2825 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2826 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827
2828 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002829 return ExprError();
2830
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 if (R.empty()) {
2832 // Rederive where we looked up.
2833 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2834 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2835 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002836
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002838 << MemberName << DC
2839 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002840 return ExprError();
2841 }
2842
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002843 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2844 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2845 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2846 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2847 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2848 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2849 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2850 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2851 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2852 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002853 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002854 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002855 return ExprError();
2856
2857 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2858 // result.
2859 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002860 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002861 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002862 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002863 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002864
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002865 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2866 // pick a member.
2867 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2868
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2870 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2871 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002872 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2873 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002874 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002875 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002876 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877
2878 return Owned(MemExpr);
2879 }
2880
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002881 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002882 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2884
2885 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2886
2887 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2888 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2889 // error cases.
2890 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2891 return ExprError();
2892
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002893 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2894 if (!BaseExpr) {
2895 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002896 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002897 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002898
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002899 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2900 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2901 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2902 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002903 }
2904
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2906 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2907 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2908 // explicitly qualified.
2909 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2910 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2911 }
2912
2913 // Check the use of this member.
2914 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2915 Owned(BaseExpr);
2916 return ExprError();
2917 }
2918
2919 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2920 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2921 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002922 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2923 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002924 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2925 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2926
2927 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2928 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2929 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2930 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2931 else {
2932 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2933 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2934 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2935
2936 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2937 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2938
2939 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2940 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2941 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2942 }
2943
2944 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002945 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946 return ExprError();
2947 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002948 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2949 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002950 }
2951
2952 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2953 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2954 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002955 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002956 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2957 }
2958
2959 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2960 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2961 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002962 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002963 MemberFn->getType()));
2964 }
2965
2966 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2967 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2968 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002969 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2970 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002971 }
2972
2973 Owned(BaseExpr);
2974
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002975 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002976 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002977 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002978 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2979 else
2980 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2981 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002982
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002983 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2984 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002985 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002986 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002987}
2988
2989/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2990/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2991/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2992/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2993/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2994/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2995/// an ordinary member expression.
2996///
2997/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2998/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002999ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003000Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003001 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003002 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003003 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003004 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003005
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003006 // Perform default conversions.
3007 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003008
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003009 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003010 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3011
3012 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3013 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003014
3015 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003016 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003017 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3018 // call, and continue on.
3019 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3020 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3021 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3022 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3023 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003024 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3025 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003026 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3027 ->isRecordType()))) {
3028 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3029 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3030 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003031 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003032
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003033 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003034 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003035 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003036 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003037 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003038
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003039 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3040 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3041 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3042 }
3043 }
3044 }
3045
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003046 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3047 // use that.
3048 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003049 if (IsArrow) {
3050 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3051 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3052 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003053 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003054 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003055 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3056 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003057 }
3058 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003059 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3060 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3061 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3062 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003063 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003064 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003065 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003067 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3068 // use that.
3069 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3070 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3071 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3072 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3073 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003074 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003075 }
3076 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003077
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003078 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003079
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003080 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003081 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003082 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3083 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3084 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3085 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3086 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3087 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3088 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3089 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3090 // Check the use of this method.
3091 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3092 return ExprError();
3093 }
3094 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3095 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3096 Selector SetterSel =
3097 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3098 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3099 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3100 if (!Setter) {
3101 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3102 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003103 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003104 }
3105 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3106 if (!Setter)
3107 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003108
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003109 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3110 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003111
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003112 if (Getter || Setter) {
3113 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003114
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003116 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003117 else
3118 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3119 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3120 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003121 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003122 PType,
3123 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3124 }
3125 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3126 << MemberName << BaseType);
3127 }
3128 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003129
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003130 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3131 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3132 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003133 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003134 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003135
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003136 if (IsArrow) {
3137 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003138 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003139 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3140 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003141 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3142 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3143 // struct MyRecord foo;
3144 // foo->bar
3145 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3146 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3147 // by now.
3148 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3149 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003150 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003151 IsArrow = false;
3152 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003153 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3154 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3155 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003156 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003157 } else {
3158 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3159 // type *foo;
3160 // foo.bar
3161 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3162 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3163 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3164 // the appropriate pointer type
3165 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3166 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3167 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3168 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3169 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003170 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003171 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3172 IsArrow = true;
3173 }
3174 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003175 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003176
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003177 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003178 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003179 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003180 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003181 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003182 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003183 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003184
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003185 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3186 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003187 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003188 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003189 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003190 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3191 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3192 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3193 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003194 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3195
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003196 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003197 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003198
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003199 if (!IV) {
3200 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3201 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3202 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003203 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003204 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003205 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003206 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3207 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003208 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3209 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003210 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003211 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003212 } else {
3213 Res.clear();
3214 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003215 }
3216 }
3217
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 if (IV) {
3219 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3220 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3221 // error cases.
3222 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3223 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003224
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003225 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3226 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3227 return ExprError();
3228 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3229 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3230 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3231 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3232 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3233 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3234 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3235 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3236 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3237 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3238 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3239 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003240 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003241 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003242 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3243 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003244 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003245 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3246 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003247
3248 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3249 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003250 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003251 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003253 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3254 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003255 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003256 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003257 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003258
3259 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3260 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003261 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003262 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003263 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003264 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003265 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003266 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003267 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003268 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3270 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003271 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003272 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003274 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003275 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003276 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3277 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3278 // Check the use of this declaration
3279 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3280 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003282 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3283 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3284 }
3285 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3286 // Check the use of this method.
3287 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3288 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianed76f442010-10-07 18:12:21 +00003289 // It is important that start and end position is the first character
3290 // and last character position of the property-dot syntax expression.
3291 SourceLocation MemberEndLoc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(MemberLoc, 1);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003292 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003293 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Fariborz Jahanianed76f442010-10-07 18:12:21 +00003294 BaseExpr->getExprLoc(),
3295 BaseExpr, Sel,
3296 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberEndLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003297 }
3298 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003299
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003300 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003301 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003302 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003303
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003304 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3305 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003306 if (!IsArrow)
3307 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3308 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003309 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003310
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003311 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003312 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003313 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3314 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003315 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003316 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003317 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003318
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003319 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003320 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003321 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003322 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3323 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003324 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003325 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003326 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003327 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003328
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003329 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3330 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3331
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003332 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003333}
3334
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003335/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3336/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3337/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3338/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3339/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3340///
3341/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3342/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3343/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3344/// only be called
3345/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3346/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3347/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003348ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003349 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3350 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003351 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003352 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003353 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003354 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3355 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3356 return ExprError();
3357
3358 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3359
3360 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003361 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3363 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003364 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003365
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003366 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3368
3369 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3370 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3371 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3372
3373 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003374 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003375 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3376 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003377
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003378 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3379 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003380 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003381 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3382 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003383 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003384 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003385 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003386 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3387 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003388
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003389 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3390 Owned(Base);
3391 return ExprError();
3392 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003393
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003394 if (Result.get()) {
3395 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3396 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3397 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3398 // call now.
3399 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3400 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003401 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003402
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003403 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003404 }
3405
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003406 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003407 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3408 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003409 }
3410
3411 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003412}
3413
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003414ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003415 FunctionDecl *FD,
3416 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3417 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003418 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003419 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3420 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003421 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003422 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003423 return ExprError();
3424 }
3425
3426 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3427 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003429 // Instantiate the expression.
3430 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3431 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003432
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003433 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3434 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3435 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3436 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003437
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003438 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3439 if (Result.isInvalid())
3440 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003441
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003442 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3443 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003444 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003445 InitializationKind Kind
3446 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3447 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3448 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003449
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003450 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3451 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3452 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3453 if (Result.isInvalid())
3454 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003455
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003456 // Build the default argument expression.
3457 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3458 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003459 }
3460
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003461 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3462 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3463 // be properly destroyed.
3464 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3465 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003466 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3467 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3468 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3469 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3470 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3471 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003472
3473 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003474 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3475 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003476 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003477 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003478}
3479
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003480/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3481/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3482/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3483/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3484/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3485/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003486bool
3487Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003488 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003489 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003490 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3491 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003492 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3494 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003495 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003496
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003497 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3498 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3499 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3500 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3501 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003502 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003503 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003504 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003505 }
3506
3507 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3508 // them.
3509 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3510 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3511 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3512 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003513 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003514 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003515 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3516 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3517 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003518 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003519 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003520 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003521 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003522 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003523 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003524 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3525 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3526 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3527 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3528 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003529 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003530 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003531 if (Invalid)
3532 return true;
3533 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3534 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3535 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003536
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003537 return false;
3538}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003539
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003540bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3541 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3542 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3543 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3544 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3545 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003546 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003547 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3548 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3549 bool Invalid = false;
3550 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3551 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3552 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3553 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003554 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003555 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003556 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003557
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003558 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003559 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3560 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003561
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003562 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3563 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003564 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003565 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003566 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003567
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003568 // Pass the argument
3569 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3570 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3571 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003572
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003573 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003574 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3575 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003576 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003577 SourceLocation(),
3578 Owned(Arg));
3579 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3580 return true;
3581
3582 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003583 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003584 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003586 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003587 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003588 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3589 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003590
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003591 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003592 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003593 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003594 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003595
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003596 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003597 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003598 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003599 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003600 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003601 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003602 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003603 }
3604 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003605 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003606}
3607
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003608/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003609/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3610/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003611ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003612Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003613 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003614 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003615
3616 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003617 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003618 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3619 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003620
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003621 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003622
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003623 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003624 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3625 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3626 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3627 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3628 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003629 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003630 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3631 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003632
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003633 NumArgs = 0;
3634 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003635
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003636 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3637 RParenLoc));
3638 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003639
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003640 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003641 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003642 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3643 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003644 bool Dependent = false;
3645 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3646 Dependent = true;
3647 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3648 Dependent = true;
3649
3650 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003651 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003652 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3653
3654 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3655 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3656 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003657 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003658
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003659 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3660
3661 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3662 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3663 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3664 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3665 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3666 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3667 // method template.
3668 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003669 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3670 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003671 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003672
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003673 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003674 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003675 }
3676
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003677 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003678 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003679 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003680 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003681 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003682 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003683 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003684
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003685 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003686 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003687 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3688 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003689 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3690 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003691 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003692
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003693 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3694 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3695 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3696 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003697
3698 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3699 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003700 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003701 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003702
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003703 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003704 RParenLoc))
3705 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003706
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003707 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003708 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003709 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003710 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3711 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003712 }
3713 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003714 }
3715
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003716 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003717 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003718 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003719
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003720 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003721 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3722 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003723 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003724 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003725 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003726
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003727 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3728 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3729 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3730
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003731 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3732}
3733
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003734/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3735/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003736/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3737/// block-pointer type.
3738///
3739/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003740ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003741Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3742 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3743 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3744 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3745 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3746
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003747 // Promote the function operand.
3748 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3749
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003750 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3751 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003752 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3753 Args, NumArgs,
3754 Context.BoolTy,
3755 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003756
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003757 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3758 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3759 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3760 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003761 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003762 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003763 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3764 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003765 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003766 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003767 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003768 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003769 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003770 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003771 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3772 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3773
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003774 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003775 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003776 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003777 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003778 return ExprError();
3779
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003780 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003781 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003782
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003783 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003784 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003785 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003786 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003787 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003788 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003789
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003790 if (FDecl) {
3791 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3792 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3793 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003794 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003795 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003796 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003797 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3798 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3799 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3800 }
3801 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003802 }
3803
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003804 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003805 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3806 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3807 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003808 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3809 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003810 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3811 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003812 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003813 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003814 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003815 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003816
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003817 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3818 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003819 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3820 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003821
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003822 // Check for sentinels
3823 if (NDecl)
3824 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003825
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003826 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003827 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003828 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003829 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003830
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003831 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003832 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003833 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003834 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003835 return ExprError();
3836 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003837
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003838 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003839}
3840
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003841ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003842Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003843 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003844 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003845 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003846 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003847
3848 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3849 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3850 if (!TInfo)
3851 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3852
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003853 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003854}
3855
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003856ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003857Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003858 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003859 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003860
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003861 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003862 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003863 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3864 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003865 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3866 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003867 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003868 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003869 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003870 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003871
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003872 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003873 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003874 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003875 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003876 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003877 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003878 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003879 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003880 &literalType);
3881 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003882 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003883 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003884
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003885 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003886 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003887 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003888 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003889 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003890
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003891 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003892 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003893}
3894
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003895ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003896Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003897 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3898 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003899 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003900
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003901 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003902 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003903
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003904 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3905 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003906 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003907 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003908}
3909
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003910static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003911 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003912 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003913 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003914
3915 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3916 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003917 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003918 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3919 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003921 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003922 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003923
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003924 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3925 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003928 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003929 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003930 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003931 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003932
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003933 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3934 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003935 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003936 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003937 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003938 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003939
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003940 // FIXME: Assert here.
3941 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003942 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003943}
3944
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003945/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003946bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003947 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003948 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003949 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003950 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003951 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3952 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003953
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003954 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003955
3956 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3957 // type needs to be scalar.
3958 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3959 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003960 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003961 return false;
3962 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003963
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003964 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3965 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3966 return true;
3967
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003968 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003969 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003970 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3971 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003972 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003973 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3974 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003975 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003976 return false;
3977 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003978
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003979 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003980 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003981 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003982 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003983 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003984 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003985 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00003986 castExpr->getType()) &&
3987 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003988 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3989 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3990 break;
3991 }
3992 }
3993 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3994 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3995 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003996 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003997 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003998 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003999
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004000 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4001 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4002 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4003 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004004
4005 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004006 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004007 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4008 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004009 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004010 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004011
4012 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004013 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004014
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004015 if (castType->isVectorType())
4016 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4017 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4018 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4019
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004020 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4021 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004022
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004023 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004024 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004025 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004026 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004027 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4028 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4029 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4030 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004031 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004032 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4033 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4034 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004035 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004036
4037 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004038
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004039 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004040 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4041
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004042 return false;
4043}
4044
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004045bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004046 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004047 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004048
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004049 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004050 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004051 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004052 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004053 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004054 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004055 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004056 } else
4057 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004058 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004059 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004060
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004061 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004062 return false;
4063}
4064
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004065bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004066 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004067 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004068
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004069 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004070
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004071 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4072 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004073 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4074 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4075 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4076 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004077 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004078 return false;
4079 }
4080
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004081 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004082 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4083 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004084 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4085 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4086 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4087 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004088
4089 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4090 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4091 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004092
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004093 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004094 return false;
4095}
4096
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004097ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004098Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004099 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4100 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004101 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004102
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004103 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4104 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4105 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004106 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004107
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004108 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4109 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004110 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004111 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004112
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004113 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004114}
4115
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004116ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004117Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004118 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004119 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004120 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004121 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004122 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004123 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004124
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004125 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004126 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004127 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4128 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004129}
4130
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004131/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4132/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004133ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004134Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004135 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4136 if (!E)
4137 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004138
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004139 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004140
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004141 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004142 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4143 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004144
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004145 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4146
4147 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004148}
4149
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004150ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004151Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004152 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004153 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004154 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004155 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004156 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004157
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004158 // Check for an altivec literal,
4159 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004160 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4161 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4162 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4163 return ExprError();
4164 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004165 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4166 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4167 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4168 }
4169 else
4170 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4171 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004172
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004173 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4174 // then handle it as such.
4175 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004176 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4177 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4178 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4179
4180 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4181 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004182 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4183 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004184 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4185 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004186 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004187 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004188 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004189 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004190 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004191 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4192 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004193 }
4194}
4195
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004196ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004197 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004198 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004199 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004200 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4201 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004202 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4203 Expr *expr;
4204 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4205 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4206 else
4207 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004208 return Owned(expr);
4209}
4210
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004211/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4212/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004213/// C99 6.5.15
4214QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004215 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004216 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004217 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4218 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004219 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004220
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004221 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004222 if (SAVE) {
4223 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4224 }
4225 else
4226 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004227 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4228 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4229 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4230 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004231
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004232 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004233 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004234 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4235 // Throw an error if its not either.
4236 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4237 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4238 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4239 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4240 << CondTy;
4241 return QualType();
4242 }
4243 }
4244 else {
4245 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4246 << CondTy;
4247 return QualType();
4248 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004249 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004250
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004251 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004252 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4253 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004254
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004255 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4256 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4257 // built in select.
4258 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4259 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4260 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4261 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4262 << CondTy;
4263 return QualType();
4264 }
4265 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4266 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4267 << CondTy;
4268 return QualType();
4269 }
4270 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4271 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4272 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4273 }
4274
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004275 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4276 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004277 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4278 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4279 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004280 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004281
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004282 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4283 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004284 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4285 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004286 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004287 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004288 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004289 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004290 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004291 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004292
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004293 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004294 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004295 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4296 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4297 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4298 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4299 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4300 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4301 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4303 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004304 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004305 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004306 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4307 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004308 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004309 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004310 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004311 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004312 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004313 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004314 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004315 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004316 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004317 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004318 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004319
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004320 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4321 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4322 QuestionLoc);
4323 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4324 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004325
4326
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004327 // Handle block pointer types.
4328 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4329 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4330 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4331 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004332 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4333 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004334 return destType;
4335 }
4336 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004337 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004338 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004339 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004340 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4341 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4342 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004343 return LHSTy;
4344 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004345 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004346 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4347 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004348
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004349 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4350 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004351 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004352 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004353 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4354 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4355 // to get a consistent AST.
4356 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004357 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4358 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004359 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004360 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004361 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004362 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4363 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004364 return LHSTy;
4365 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004366
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004367 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4368 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4369 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004370 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4371 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004372
4373 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4374 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4375 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004376 QualType destPointee
4377 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004378 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004379 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004380 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004381 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004382 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004383 return destType;
4384 }
4385 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004386 QualType destPointee
4387 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004388 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004389 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004390 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004391 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004392 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004393 return destType;
4394 }
4395
4396 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4397 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4398 return LHSTy;
4399 }
4400 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4401 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4402 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4403 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4404 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4405 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4406 // to get a consistent AST.
4407 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004408 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4409 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004410 return incompatTy;
4411 }
4412 // The pointer types are compatible.
4413 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4414 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4415 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4416 // type.
4417 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4418 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004419 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4420 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004421 return LHSTy;
4422 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004423
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004424 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4425 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4426 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4427 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004428 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004429 return RHSTy;
4430 }
4431 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4432 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4433 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004434 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004435 return LHSTy;
4436 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004437
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004438 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004439 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4440 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004441 return QualType();
4442}
4443
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004444/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4445/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4446QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4447 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4448 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4449 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004450
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004451 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4452 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4453 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4454 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4455 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004456 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004457 return LHSTy;
4458 }
4459 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4460 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004461 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004462 return RHSTy;
4463 }
4464 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4465 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4466 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004467 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004468 return LHSTy;
4469 }
4470 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4471 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004472 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004473 return RHSTy;
4474 }
4475 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4476 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4477 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004478 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004479 return LHSTy;
4480 }
4481 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4482 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004483 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004484 return RHSTy;
4485 }
4486 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4487 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004488
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004489 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4490 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4491 return LHSTy;
4492 }
4493 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4494 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4495 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004496
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004497 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4498 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4499 // type. This allows
4500 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4501 // where B is a subclass of A.
4502 //
4503 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4504 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4505 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4506 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004507
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004508 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4509 // It could return the composite type.
4510 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4511 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4512 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4513 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4514 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4515 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4516 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4517 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4518 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4519 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4520 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4521 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4522 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4523 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004524 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004525 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4526 ;
4527 else {
4528 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4529 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4530 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4531 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004532 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4533 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004534 return incompatTy;
4535 }
4536 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004537 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4538 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004539 return compositeType;
4540 }
4541 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4542 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4543 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4544 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4545 QualType destPointee
4546 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4547 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4548 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004549 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004550 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004551 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004552 return destType;
4553 }
4554 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4555 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4556 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4557 QualType destPointee
4558 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4559 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4560 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004561 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004562 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004563 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004564 return destType;
4565 }
4566 return QualType();
4567}
4568
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004569/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004570/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004571ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004572 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004573 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4574 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004575 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4576 // was the condition.
4577 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004578 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4579 if (isLHSNull) {
4580 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4581 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004582
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004583 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4584 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004585 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004586 return ExprError();
4587
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004588 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004589 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4590 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4591 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004592}
4593
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004594// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004595// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004596// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4597// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4598// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004599Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004600Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4601 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004602
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004603 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4604 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4605 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4606 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4607 return Compatible;
4608 }
4609
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004610 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004611 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4612 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004613
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004614 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004615 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4616 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004617
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004618 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004619
4620 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4621 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4622 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004623 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004624 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004625 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004626
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004627 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4628 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004629 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004630 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004631 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004632 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004633
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004634 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004635 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4636 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004637 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004639 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004640 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004641 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004642
4643 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004644 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4645 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004646 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004647 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004648 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004649 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4650 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4651 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4652 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4653 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4654 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004655 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004656 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004657 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004658 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004659
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004660 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004661 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004662 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004663 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004664
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004665 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4666 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4667 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4668 // warning can be disabled.
4669 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4670 return ConvTy;
4671 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4672 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004673
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004674 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4675 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4676 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4677 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4678 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4679 do {
4680 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4681 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004682
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004683 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4684 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4685 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004686
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004687 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004688 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004689 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004690
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004691 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004692 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004693 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004694 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004695}
4696
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004697/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4698/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4699/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4700// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004701Sema::AssignConvertType
4702Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004703 QualType rhsType) {
4704 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004705
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004706 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004707 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4708 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004709
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004710 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4711 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4712 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004713
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004714 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004715
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004716 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004717 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004718 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004719
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004720 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4721 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4722 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4723 }
4724 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004725 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004726 return ConvTy;
4727}
4728
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004729/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4730/// for assignment compatibility.
4731Sema::AssignConvertType
4732Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004733 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4734 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004735 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4736 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004737 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004738 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004739 }
4740 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4741 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004742 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4743 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004744 return IncompatiblePointer;
4745 return Compatible;
4746 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004747 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004748 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004749 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004750 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4751 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4752 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4753 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4754 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4755 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004756
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004757 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4758 return Compatible;
4759 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4760 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004761 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004762}
4763
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004764/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4765/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004766/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4767///
4768/// int a, *pint;
4769/// short *pshort;
4770/// struct foo *pfoo;
4771///
4772/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4773/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4774/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4775/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4776///
4777/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004778/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004779///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004780Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004781Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004782 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4783 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004784 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4785 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004786
4787 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004788 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004789
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004790 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4791 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4792 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4793 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4794 return Compatible;
4795 }
4796
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004797 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4798 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4799 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4800 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4801 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4802 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4803 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004804 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004805 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004806 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004807 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004808 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004809 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4810 // to the same ExtVector type.
4811 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4812 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4813 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004814 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004815 return Compatible;
4816 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004817
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004818 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004819 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4820 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4821 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4822 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4823 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4824 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004825 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004826
4827 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4828 // vector type and vice versa
4829 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4830 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004831 }
4832 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004833 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004834
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004835 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4836 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004837 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004838
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004839 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004840 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004841 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004842
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004843 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004844 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004845
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004846 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004847 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004848 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4849 return Compatible;
4850 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004851 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004852 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4853 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004854 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004855
4856 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004857 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004858 return Compatible;
4859 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004860 return Incompatible;
4861 }
4862
4863 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4864 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004865 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004866
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004867 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004868 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004869 return Compatible;
4870
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004871 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4872 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004873
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004874 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004875 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004876 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004877 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004878 return Incompatible;
4879 }
4880
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004881 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4882 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4883 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004884
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004885 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004886 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004887 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4888 return Compatible;
4889 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004890 }
4891 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004892 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004893 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004894 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004895 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4896 return Compatible;
4897 }
4898 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4899 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4900 return Compatible;
4901 return Incompatible;
4902 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004903 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004904 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004905 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4906 return Compatible;
4907
4908 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004909 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004910
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004911 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004912 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004913
4914 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004915 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004916 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004917 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004918 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004919 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4920 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4921 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4922 return Compatible;
4923
4924 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4925 return PointerToInt;
4926
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004927 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004928 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004929 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4930 return Compatible;
4931 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004932 }
4933 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004934 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004935 return Compatible;
4936 return Incompatible;
4937 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004938
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004939 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004940 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004941 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004942 }
4943 return Incompatible;
4944}
4945
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004946/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4947/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004948static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004949 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4950 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4951 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004952 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004953 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004954 SourceLocation());
4955 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4956 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4957
4958 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4959 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004960 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004961 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004962 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004963}
4964
4965Sema::AssignConvertType
4966Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4967 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4968
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004969 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004970 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4971 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004972 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004973 return Incompatible;
4974
4975 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4976 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4977 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4978 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004979 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4980 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004981 it != itend; ++it) {
4982 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4983 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4984 // 1) void pointer
4985 // 2) null pointer constant
4986 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004987 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004988 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004989 InitField = *it;
4990 break;
4991 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004992
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004993 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004994 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004995 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004996 InitField = *it;
4997 break;
4998 }
4999 }
5000
5001 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5002 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005003 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005004 InitField = *it;
5005 break;
5006 }
5007 }
5008
5009 if (!InitField)
5010 return Incompatible;
5011
5012 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5013 return Compatible;
5014}
5015
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005016Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005017Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005018 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5019 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5020 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5021 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5022 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005023 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005024 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005025 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005026 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005027 }
5028
5029 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5030 // structures.
5031 }
5032
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005033 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5034 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005035 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5036 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005037 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005038 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005039 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005040 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005041 return Compatible;
5042 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005043
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005044 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005045 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005046 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005047 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005048 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005049 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005050 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005051 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005052
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005053 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5054 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005055
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005056 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5057 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005058 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5059 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5060 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5061 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005062 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005063 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005064 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005065 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005066}
5067
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005068QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005069 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005070 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005071 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005072 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005073}
5074
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005075QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005076 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005077 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005078 QualType lhsType =
5079 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5080 QualType rhsType =
5081 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005082
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005083 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005084 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005085 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005086
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005087 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5088 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005089 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005090 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005091 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005092 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005093 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005094 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005095 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005096 return lhsType;
5097 }
5098
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005099 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005100 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005101 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5102 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5103 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5104 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5105 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5106 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005107 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005108 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005109 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005110 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005111
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005112 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5113 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5114 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005115 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005116 return rhsType;
5117 }
5118
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005119 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5120 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5121 bool swapped = false;
5122 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5123 swapped = true;
5124 std::swap(rex, lex);
5125 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5126 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005127
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005128 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005129 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005130 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005131 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005132 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005133 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005134 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5135 return lhsType;
5136 }
5137 }
5138 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5139 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5140 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005141 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005142 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5143 return lhsType;
5144 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005145 }
5146 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005147
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005148 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005149 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005150 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005151 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005152 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005153}
5154
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005155QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5156 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005157 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005158 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005159
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005160 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005161
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005162 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5163 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5164 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005165
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005166 // Check for division by zero.
5167 if (isDiv &&
5168 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005169 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005170 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005171
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005172 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005173}
5174
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005175QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005176 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005177 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005178 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5179 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005180 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5181 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5182 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005183
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005184 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005185
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005186 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5187 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005188
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005189 // Check for remainder by zero.
5190 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005191 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5192 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005193
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005194 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005195}
5196
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005197QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005198 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005199 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5200 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5201 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5202 return compType;
5203 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005204
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005205 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005206
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005207 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005208 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5209 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5210 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005211 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005212 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005213
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005214 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5215 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005216 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005217 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5218
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005219 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005220
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005221 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005222 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005223
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005224 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5225 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005226 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5227 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005228 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005229 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005230 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005231
5232 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5233 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5234 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005235 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005236 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5237 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5238 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5239 return QualType();
5240 }
5241
5242 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5243 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5244 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005245 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005246 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005247 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005248 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005249 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5250 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005251 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5252 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005253 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005254 return QualType();
5255 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005256 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005257 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005258 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5259 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5260 return QualType();
5261 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005262
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005263 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005264 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5265 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5266 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5267 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5268 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005269 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005270 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5271 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005272 return PExp->getType();
5273 }
5274 }
5275
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005276 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005277}
5278
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005279// C99 6.5.6
5280QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005281 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5282 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5283 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5284 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5285 return compType;
5286 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005287
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005288 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005289
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005290 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005291
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005292 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005293 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5294 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005295 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005296 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005297 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005298
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005299 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005300 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005301 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005302
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005303 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005304
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005305 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5306 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5307 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5308 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5310 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5311 return QualType();
5312 }
5313
5314 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5315 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5316 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5317 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5318 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005319 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005320 return QualType();
5321 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005322
5323 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5324 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5325 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005326 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005327 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005328 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005329 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005330 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005331
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005332 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005333 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005334 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5335 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5336 return QualType();
5337 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005338
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005339 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005340 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5341 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5342 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5343 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5344 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5345 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005346 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005347 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5348
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005349 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005350 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005351 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005352
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005353 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005354 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005355 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005356
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005357 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5358 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5359 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5360 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5361 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5362 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5363 return QualType();
5364 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005365
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005366 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5367 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5368 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5369 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005370 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005371 return QualType();
5372 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005373
5374 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5375 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5376 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5377 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5378 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005379 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5380 << rex->getSourceRange()
5381 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005382 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005383
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005384 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5385 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5386 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5387 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5388 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5389 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5390 return QualType();
5391 }
5392 } else {
5393 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5394 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5395 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5396 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5397 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5398 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5399 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5400 return QualType();
5401 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005402 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005403
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005404 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5405 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5406 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5407 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5408 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005409 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005410 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005411
5412 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005413 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5414 }
5415 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005416
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005417 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005418}
5419
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005420static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5421 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5422 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5423 return false;
5424}
5425
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005426// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005427QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005428 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005429 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005430 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5431 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005432 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005433
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005434 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5435 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5436 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5437 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5438 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5439 }
5440
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005441 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5442 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5443 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5444
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005445 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5446 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005447 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5448 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5449 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5450 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5451 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005452 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005453 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005454 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005455
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005456 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005457
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005458 // Sanity-check shift operands
5459 llvm::APSInt Right;
5460 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005461 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5462 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005463 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005464 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5465 else {
5466 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5467 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5468 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5469 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5470 }
5471 }
5472
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005473 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005474 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005475}
5476
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005477static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5478 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5479 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5480 return true;
5481 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5482 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5483 }
5484 return false;
5485}
5486
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005487// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005488QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005489 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005490 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005491
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005492 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005493 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005494 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005495
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005496 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5497 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005498
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005499 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005500 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5501 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5502 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005503 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5504 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5505 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005506 //
5507 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5508 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5509 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5510 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5511 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5512 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005513 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5514 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005515 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005516 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005517 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005518 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005519 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5520 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005521 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5522 || Opc == BO_LE
5523 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005524 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5525 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5526 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5527 // what is it always going to eval to?
5528 char always_evals_to;
5529 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005530 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005531 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5532 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005533 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005534 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5535 break;
5536 default:
5537 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5538 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5539 break;
5540 }
5541 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5542 << 1 // array
5543 << always_evals_to);
5544 }
5545 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005546 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005547
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005548 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5549 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5550 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5551 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005552
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005553 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5554 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005555 Expr *literalString = 0;
5556 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005557 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005558 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005559 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005560 literalString = lex;
5561 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005562 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5563 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005564 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005565 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005566 literalString = rex;
5567 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5568 }
5569
5570 if (literalString) {
5571 std::string resultComparison;
5572 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005573 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5574 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5575 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5576 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5577 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5578 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005579 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5580 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005581
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005582 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5583 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5584 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005585 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005586 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005587 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005588
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005589 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5590 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5591 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5592 else {
5593 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5594 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5595 }
5596
5597 lType = lex->getType();
5598 rType = rex->getType();
5599
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005600 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005601 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005602
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005603 if (isRelational) {
5604 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005605 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005606 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005607 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005608 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005609 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005610
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005611 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005612 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005613 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005614
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005615 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005616 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005617 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005618 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005620 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5621 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005622 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005623 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005624 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005625 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005626 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005627
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005628 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005629 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5630 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005631 if (!isRelational &&
5632 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5633 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5634 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005635 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5636 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005637 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5638 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005639 Diag(Loc,
5640 isSFINAEContext()?
5641 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5642 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005643 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005644
5645 if (isSFINAEContext())
5646 return QualType();
5647
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005648 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005649 return ResultTy;
5650 }
5651 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005652 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5653 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5654 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5655 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5656 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5657 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005658 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005659 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005660 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005661 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005662 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005663 if (T.isNull()) {
5664 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5665 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5666 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005667 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005668 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005669 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005670 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005671 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005672 }
5673
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005674 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5675 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005676 return ResultTy;
5677 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005678 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5679 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5680 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5681 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5682 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5683 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5684 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5685 }
5686 } else if (!isRelational &&
5687 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5688 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5689 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5690 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5691 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5692 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5693 }
5694 } else {
5695 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005696 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005697 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005698 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005699 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005700 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005701 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005702 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005703
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005704 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005705 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005706 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005707 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005708 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5709 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005710 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5711 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005712 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5713 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005714 return ResultTy;
5715 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005716 if (LHSIsNull &&
5717 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5718 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005719 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5720 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005721 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5722 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005723 return ResultTy;
5724 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005725
5726 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005727 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005728 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5729 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005730 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5731 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5732 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5733 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5734 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5735 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5736 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5737 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005738 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005739 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005740 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005741 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005742 if (T.isNull()) {
5743 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005744 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005745 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005746 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005747 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005748 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005749 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005750 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005751 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005752
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005753 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5754 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005755 return ResultTy;
5756 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005757
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005758 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005759 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5760 return ResultTy;
5761 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005762
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005763 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005764 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005765 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5766 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005767
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005768 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005769 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005770 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005771 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005772 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005773 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005774 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005775 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005776 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005777 if (!isRelational
5778 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5779 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005780 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005781 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005782 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005783 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005784 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5785 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5786 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005787 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005788 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005789 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005790 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005791
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005792 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005793 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005794 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5795 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005796 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005797 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005798 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005799 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005800
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005801 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5802 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005803 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005804 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005805 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005806 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005807 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005808 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005809 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005810 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005811 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5812 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005813 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005814 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005815 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005816 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005817 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5818 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005819 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005820 bool isError = false;
5821 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5822 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5823 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005824 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005825 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005826 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005827 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5828 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5829 isError = true;
5830 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005831 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005832
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005833 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005834 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005835 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005836 if (isError)
5837 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005838 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005839
5840 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005841 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005842 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005843 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005844 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005845 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005846
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005847 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005848 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5849 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005850 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005851 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005852 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005853 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5854 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005855 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005856 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005857 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005858 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005859}
5860
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005861/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005862/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005863/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5864/// types.
5865QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005866 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005867 bool isRelational) {
5868 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5869 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005870 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005871 if (vType.isNull())
5872 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005873
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005874 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5875 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005876
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005877 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5878 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5879 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005880 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005881 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5882 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5883 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005884 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5885 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5886 << 0 // self-
5887 << 2 // "a constant"
5888 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005889 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005890
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005891 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005892 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5893 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005894 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005895 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005896
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005897 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5898 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5899 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005900 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005901 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005902
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005903 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005904 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005905 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005906 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005907 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005908 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5909
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005910 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005911 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005912 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5913}
5914
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005915inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005916 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005917 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5918 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5919 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5920 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5921
5922 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5923 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005924
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005925 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005926
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005927 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5928 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005929 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005930 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005931}
5932
5933inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005934 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5935
5936 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5937 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5938 // is a constant.
5939 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005940 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005941 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005942 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5943 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5944 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5945 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5946 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5947 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5948 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5949 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5950 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005951 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5952 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005953 }
5954 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005955
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005956 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5957 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5958 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005959
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005960 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5961 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005962
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005963 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005964 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005965
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005966 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5967 // non-overloadable operands.
5968
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005969 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5970 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005971 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5972 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5973 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005974 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005975
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005976 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5977 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5978 // The result is a bool.
5979 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005980}
5981
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005982/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5983/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5984/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5985///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005986static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005987 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5988 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5989 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5990 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005991 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005992 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5993 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5994 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5995 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005996 }
5997 }
5998 return false;
5999}
6000
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006001/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6002/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6003static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006004 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006005 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006006 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006007 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6008 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006009 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6010 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006011
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006012 unsigned Diag = 0;
6013 bool NeedType = false;
6014 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006015 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006016 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006017 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6018 NeedType = true;
6019 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006020 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006021 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6022 NeedType = true;
6023 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006024 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006025 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6026 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006027 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6028 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006029 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006030 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6031 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006032 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6033 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006034 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6035 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006036 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006037 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006038 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006039 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006040 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6041 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006042 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006043 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6044 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006045 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6046 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6047 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006048 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6049 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6050 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006051 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6052 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6053 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006054 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006055
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006056 SourceRange Assign;
6057 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6058 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006059 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006060 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006061 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006062 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006063 return true;
6064}
6065
6066
6067
6068// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006069QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6070 SourceLocation Loc,
6071 QualType CompoundType) {
6072 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6073 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006074 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006075
6076 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6077 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006078 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006079 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006080 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006081 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006082 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006083 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006084 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6085 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6086 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006087 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006088 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006089 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006090 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006091
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006092 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6093 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6094 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006095 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006096 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6097 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6098 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006099 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6100 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006101 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006102 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006103 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6104 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6105 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006106 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6107 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006108 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006109 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006110 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006111 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006112 }
6113 } else {
6114 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006115 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006116 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006117
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006118 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006119 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006120 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006121
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006122
6123 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6124 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6125 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6126 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6127 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6128 // check.
6129 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006130 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006131 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6132 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6133 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6134 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6135 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6136 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6137 }
6138
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006139 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6140 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006141 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006142 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6143 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006144 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006145 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006146 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006147}
6148
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006149// C99 6.5.17
6150QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006151 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6152
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006153 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006154 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6155 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6156 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006157
6158 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6159 // incomplete in C++).
6160
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006161 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006162}
6163
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006164/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6165/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006166QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006167 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006168 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6169 return Context.DependentTy;
6170
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006171 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6172 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006173
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006174 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6175 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6176 if (!isInc) {
6177 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6178 return QualType();
6179 }
6180 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6181 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6182 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006183 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006184 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6185 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006186
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006187 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006188 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006189 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6190 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6191 << Op->getSourceRange();
6192 return QualType();
6193 }
6194
6195 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006196 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006197 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006198 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6199 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6200 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6201 return QualType();
6202 }
6203
6204 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006205 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006206 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006207 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006208 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006209 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006210 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006211 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006212 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006213 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6214 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6215 return QualType();
6216 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006217 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006218 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6219 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006220 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006221 } else {
6222 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006223 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006224 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006225 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006226 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006227 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006228 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006229 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006230 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6231 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6232 // operand.
6233 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6234 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006235}
6236
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006237void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6238 bool copyInit = false;
6239 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6240 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6241 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6242 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6243 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6244 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6245 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6246 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6247 }
6248 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6249 }
6250 else
6251 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6252 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6253 if (copyInit) {
6254 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006255 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006256 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6257 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6258 Owned(Arg));
6259 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006260 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006261 }
6262}
6263
6264
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006265/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006266/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006267/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6268/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6269/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6270/// - &(x) => x
6271/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6272/// - &s.xx => s
6273/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6274/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6275/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6276/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006277static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006278 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006279 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006280 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006281 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006282 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6283 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6284 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006285 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006286 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006287 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006288 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006289 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006290 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6291 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006292 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6293 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6294 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6295 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6296 }
6297 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006298 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006299 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6300 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006301
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006302 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006303 case UO_Real:
6304 case UO_Imag:
6305 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006306 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6307 default:
6308 return 0;
6309 }
6310 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006311 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006312 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006313 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006314 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6315 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006316 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006317 default:
6318 return 0;
6319 }
6320}
6321
6322/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006323/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006324/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006325/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006326/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006327/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006328/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006329QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6330 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006331 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006332 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6333 return Context.OverloadTy;
6334
6335 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6336 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006337
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006338 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6339 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6340 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006341 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006342 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6343 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6344 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6345 }
6346 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6347 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6348 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006349 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006350 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006351
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006352 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006353 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6354 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6355 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6356 if (isSFINAEContext())
6357 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006358 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006359 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006360 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6361 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6362 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6363
6364 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6365 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6366 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6367 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6368 return QualType();
6369 }
6370 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6371 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6372
6373 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6374 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6375 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6376 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6377
6378 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6379 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6380 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6381 << op->getSourceRange();
6382 }
6383
6384 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6385 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6386 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006387 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006388 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006389 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006390 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006391 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6392 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006393 return QualType();
6394 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006395 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006396 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6397 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6398 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006399 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006400 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006401 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006402 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006403 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006404 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006405 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6406 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6407 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6408 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6409 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006410 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6411 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006412 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6413 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006414 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006415 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006416 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6417 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006418 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6419 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006420 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006421 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006422 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6423 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006424 return QualType();
6425 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006426 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006427 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006428 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006429 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006430 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6431 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006432 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006433 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006434 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6435 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006436 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006437 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6438 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6439 return QualType();
6440 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006441
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006442 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6443 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006444 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006445 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006446 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006447 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006448 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006449
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006450 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6451 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6452 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6453 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6455 }
6456
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006457 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006458 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6459 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006460 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6461}
6462
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006463/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006464QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006465 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6466 return Context.DependentTy;
6467
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006468 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006469 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6470 QualType Result;
6471
6472 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6473 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6474 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6475 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6476 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6477 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6478 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6479 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6480 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006481
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006482 if (Result.isNull()) {
6483 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6484 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6485 return QualType();
6486 }
6487
6488 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006489}
6490
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006491static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006492 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006493 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006494 switch (Kind) {
6495 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006496 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6497 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6498 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6499 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6500 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6501 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6502 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6503 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6504 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6505 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6506 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6507 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6508 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6509 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6510 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6511 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6512 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6513 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6514 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6515 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6516 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6517 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6518 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6519 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6520 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6521 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6522 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6523 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6524 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6525 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6526 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6527 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006528 }
6529 return Opc;
6530}
6531
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006532static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006533 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006534 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006535 switch (Kind) {
6536 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006537 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6538 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6539 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6540 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6541 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6542 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6543 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6544 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6545 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6546 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6547 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006548 }
6549 return Opc;
6550}
6551
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006552/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6553/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6554/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006555ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006556 unsigned Op,
6557 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006558 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006559 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006560 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6561 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6562 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006563
6564 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006565 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006566 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6567 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006568 case BO_PtrMemD:
6569 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006570 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006571 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006572 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006573 case BO_Mul:
6574 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006575 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006576 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006577 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006578 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006579 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6580 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006581 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006582 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6583 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006584 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006585 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6586 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006587 case BO_Shl:
6588 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006589 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6590 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006591 case BO_LE:
6592 case BO_LT:
6593 case BO_GE:
6594 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006595 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006596 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006597 case BO_EQ:
6598 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006599 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006600 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006601 case BO_And:
6602 case BO_Xor:
6603 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006604 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6605 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006606 case BO_LAnd:
6607 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006608 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006609 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006610 case BO_MulAssign:
6611 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006612 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006613 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006614 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6615 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6616 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006617 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006618 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006619 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6620 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6621 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6622 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006623 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006624 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006625 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6626 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6627 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006628 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006629 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006630 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6631 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6632 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006633 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006634 case BO_ShlAssign:
6635 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006636 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6637 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6638 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6639 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006640 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006641 case BO_AndAssign:
6642 case BO_XorAssign:
6643 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006644 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6645 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6646 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6647 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006648 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006649 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006650 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6651 break;
6652 }
6653 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006654 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006655 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006656 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006657 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6658 << ResultTy;
6659 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006660 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006661 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6662 else
6663 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006664 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6665 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006666}
6667
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006668/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6669/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006670static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6671 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006672 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6673 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6674 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006675 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006676 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6677
6678 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6679 return;
6680
6681 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6682 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6683 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006684 return;
6685 }
6686
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006687 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6688 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006689 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006690
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006691 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006692 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006693
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006694 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6695 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6696 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6697 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006698 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006699 return;
6700 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006701
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006702 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006703 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6704 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006705}
6706
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006707/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6708/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6709/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6710/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006711static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006712 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006713 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6714 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6715 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6716 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006717 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006718 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006719 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6720
6721 // Subs are not binary operators.
6722 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6723 return;
6724
6725 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6726 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006727 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6728 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006729 return;
6730
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006731 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006732 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006733 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006734 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6735 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006736 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006737 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006738 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6739 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6740 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6741 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006742 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006743 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006744 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006745 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6746 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006747 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006748 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006749 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6750 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6751 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6752 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006753}
6754
6755/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6756/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6757/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006758static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006759 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006760 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006761 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6762}
6763
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006764// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006765ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006766 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6767 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6768 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006769 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6770 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006771
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006772 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6773 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6774
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006775 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6776}
6777
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006778ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006779 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6780 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006781 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006782 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6783 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006784 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006785 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006786 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6787 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6788 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6789 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6790 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006791 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006792 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006793 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6794 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6795 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006796
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006797 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6798 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006799 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006800 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006801
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006802 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006803 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006804}
6805
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006806ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006807 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006808 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006809 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006810
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006811 QualType resultType;
6812 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006813 case UO_PreInc:
6814 case UO_PreDec:
6815 case UO_PostInc:
6816 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006817 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006818 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6819 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6820 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6821 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006822 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006823 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006824 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6825 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006826 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006827 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006828 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6829 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006830 case UO_Plus:
6831 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006832 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6833 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006834 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6835 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006836 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6837 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006838 break;
6839 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6840 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6841 break;
6842 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006843 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006844 resultType->isPointerType())
6845 break;
6846
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006847 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6848 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006849 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006850 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6851 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006852 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6853 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006854 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6855 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6856 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006857 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006858 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006859 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006860 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6861 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006862 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006863 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006864 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006865 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006866 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006867 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6868 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006869 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006870 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6871 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006872
6873 // Do not accept &f if f is overloaded
6874 // i.e. void f(int); void f(char); bool b = &f;
6875 if (resultType == Context.OverloadTy &&
6876 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Input))
6877 return ExprError(); // Diagnostic is uttered above
6878
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006879 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006880 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6881 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006882 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006883 case UO_Real:
6884 case UO_Imag:
6885 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006886 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006887 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006888 resultType = Input->getType();
6889 break;
6890 }
6891 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006892 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006893
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006894 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006895}
6896
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006897ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006898 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6899 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006900 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006901 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006902 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6903 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6904 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6905 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006906 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006907 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006908 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6909 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6910 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006911
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006912 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006913 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006914
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006915 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006916}
6917
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006918// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006919ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006920 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6921 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006922}
6923
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006924/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006925ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006926 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6927 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006928 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006929 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006930
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006931 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6932 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006933 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006934 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006935
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006936 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006937 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006938 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6939 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006940}
6941
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006942ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006943Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006944 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006945 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6946 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6947
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006948 bool isFileScope
6949 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006950 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006951 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006952
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006953 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6954 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6955 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006956
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006957 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6958 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6959 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006960
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006961 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6962 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6963 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6964 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6965 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006966
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006967 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006968 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006969 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006970
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006971 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6972 // expressions are not lvalues.
6973
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006974 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006975}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006976
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006977ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006978 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006979 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6980 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006981 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6982 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006983 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006984 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006985
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006986 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6987 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6988 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006989 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006990 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6991 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6992
6993 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6994 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6995 if (!Dependent
6996 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6997 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6998 << TypeRange))
6999 return ExprError();
7000
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007001 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7002 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007003 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7004 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007005 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007006 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7007 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007008
7009 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7010 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7011 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7012 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7013 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7014 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7015 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7016 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7017 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7018 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7019 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7020 if(!AT)
7021 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7022 << CurrentType);
7023 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7024 } else
7025 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7026
7027 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7028 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7029 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7030 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7031 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7032 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7033 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7034 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7035
7036 // Record this array index.
7037 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7038 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7039 continue;
7040 }
7041
7042 // Offset of a field.
7043 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7044 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7045 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7046 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7047 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7048 continue;
7049 }
7050
7051 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7052 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7053 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7054 return ExprError();
7055
7056 // Look for the designated field.
7057 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7058 if (!RC)
7059 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7060 << CurrentType);
7061 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7062
7063 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7064 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7065 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7066 // (clause 9).
7067 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7068 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7069 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7070 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7071 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7072 << CurrentType))
7073 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7074 }
7075
7076 // Look for the field.
7077 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7078 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7079 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7080 if (!MemberDecl)
7081 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7082 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7083 OC.LocEnd));
7084
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007085 // C99 7.17p3:
7086 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7087 //
7088 // We diagnose this as an error.
7089 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7090 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7091 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7092 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7093 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7094 return ExprError();
7095 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007096
7097 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7098 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7099 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7100 do {
7101 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7102 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7103 }
7104
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007105 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7106 // the base class indirections.
7107 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7108 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007109 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007110 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7111 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7112 B != BEnd; ++B)
7113 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7114 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007115
7116 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007117 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7118 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7119 unsigned n = Path.size();
7120 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7121 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7122 } else {
7123 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7124 }
7125 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7126 }
7127
7128 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7129 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7130 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7131}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007132
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007133ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007134 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7135 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007136 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007137 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7138 unsigned NumComponents,
7139 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7140
7141 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7142 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7143 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7144 return ExprError();
7145
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007146 if (!ArgTInfo)
7147 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7148
7149 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7150 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007151}
7152
7153
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007154ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007155 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007156 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007157 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7158 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7159 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7160 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007161
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007162 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007163
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007164 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7165}
7166
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007167ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007168Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7169 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7170 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7171 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007172 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7173 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7174 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7175 return ExprError();
7176 }
7177
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007178 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007179 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007180}
7181
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007182
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007183ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007184 Expr *CondExpr,
7185 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007186 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007187 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7188
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007189 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007190 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007191 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007192 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007193 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007194 } else {
7195 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7196 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7197 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7198 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007199 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7200 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7201 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007202
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007203 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7204 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007205 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7206 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007207 }
7208
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007209 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007210 resType, RPLoc,
7211 resType->isDependentType(),
7212 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007213}
7214
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007215//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7216// Clang Extensions.
7217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7218
7219/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007220void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007221 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7222 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7223 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007224 if (BlockScope)
7225 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7226 else
7227 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007228}
7229
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007230void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007231 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007232 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007233
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007234 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007235 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007236 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007237
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007238 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007239 QualType RetTy;
7240 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007241 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007242 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007243 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007244 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7245 } else {
7246 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007247 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007248 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007249
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007250 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007251
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007252 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7253 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7254 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007255 return;
7256 }
7257
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007258 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7259 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7260 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7261 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7262 return;
7263 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007264
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007265 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007266 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7267 // ^ * { ... }
7268 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007269 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7270 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007271
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007272 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007273 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007274 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7275 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7276 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7277 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007278 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7279 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7280 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7281 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7282 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007283 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007284 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007285
7286 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7287 // ^ fntype { ... }
7288 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7289 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7290 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7291 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7292 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7293 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7294 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007295 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007296 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007297 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007298
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007299 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7300 if (!Params.empty())
7301 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007302
7303 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007304 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007305
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007306 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007307 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7308 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7309 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7310 }
7311
7312 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7313 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007314 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007315 return;
7316
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007317 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7318 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7319
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007320 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007321 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7322 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7323
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007324 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007325 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7326 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7327 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7328
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007329 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007330 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007331 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007332}
7333
7334/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7335/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7336void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007337 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007338 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007339 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007340 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007341}
7342
7343/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7344/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007345ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007346 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007347 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7348 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7349 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007350
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007351 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007352
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007353 PopDeclContext();
7354
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007355 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007356 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7357 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007358
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007359 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007360 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007361
7362 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7363 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7364 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7365
7366 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7367 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7368
7369 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7370 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7371 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7372 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7373
7374 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7375 // preserve its sugar structure.
7376 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7377 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7378 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7379
7380 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7381 } else {
7382 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7383 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7384 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7385 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7386 FPT->isVariadic(),
7387 /*quals*/ 0,
7388 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7389 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7390 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7391 FPT->exception_begin(),
7392 Ext);
7393 }
7394
7395 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7396 } else {
7397 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7398 false, false, 0, 0,
7399 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7400 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007401
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007402 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007403 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7404 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007405 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007406
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007407 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007408 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007409 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007410
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007411 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007412
7413 bool Good = true;
7414 // Check goto/label use.
7415 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7416 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7417 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7418
7419 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7420 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007421 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7422 if (!L->isUsed())
7423 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007424 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007425 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007426
7427 // Emit error.
7428 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7429 Good = false;
7430 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007431 if (!Good) {
7432 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007433 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007434 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007435
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007436 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7437 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7438
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007439 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007440 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7441 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007442 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007443
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007444 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007445 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007446}
7447
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007448ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007449 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007450 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007451 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7452 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007453 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007454}
7455
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007456ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007457 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007458 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007459 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007460
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007461 // Get the va_list type
7462 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007463 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7464 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7465 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7466 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007467 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007468 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7469 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7470 } else {
7471 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7472 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007473 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007474 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007475 return ExprError();
7476 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007477
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007478 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7479 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007480 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7481 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007482 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007483 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007484
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007485 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007486 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007487
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007488 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7489 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007490}
7491
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007492ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007493 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7494 // pointers on the target.
7495 QualType Ty;
7496 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7497 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7498 else
7499 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7500
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007501 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007502}
7503
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007504static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007505 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007506 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7507 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007508
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007509 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7510 if (!PT)
7511 return;
7512
7513 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7514 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7515 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7516 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7517 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7518 return;
7519 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007520
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007521 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7522 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7523 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7524 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007525
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007526 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007527}
7528
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007529bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7530 SourceLocation Loc,
7531 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007532 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7533 bool *Complained) {
7534 if (Complained)
7535 *Complained = false;
7536
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007537 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7538 bool isInvalid = false;
7539 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007540 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007541
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007542 switch (ConvTy) {
7543 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7544 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007545 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007546 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7547 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007548 case IntToPointer:
7549 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7550 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007551 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007552 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007553 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7554 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007555 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7556 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7557 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007558 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7559 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7560 break;
7561 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007562 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7563 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7564 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7565 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7566 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7567 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7568 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7569 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7570 // C++ semantics.
7571 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7572 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7573 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007574 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7575 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007576 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007577 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007578 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007579 case IntToBlockPointer:
7580 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7581 break;
7582 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007583 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007584 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007585 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007586 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007587 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7588 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7589 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007590 case IncompatibleVectors:
7591 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7592 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007593 case Incompatible:
7594 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7595 isInvalid = true;
7596 break;
7597 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007598
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007599 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7600 switch (Action) {
7601 case AA_Assigning:
7602 case AA_Initializing:
7603 // The destination type comes first.
7604 FirstType = DstType;
7605 SecondType = SrcType;
7606 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007607
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007608 case AA_Returning:
7609 case AA_Passing:
7610 case AA_Converting:
7611 case AA_Sending:
7612 case AA_Casting:
7613 // The source type comes first.
7614 FirstType = SrcType;
7615 SecondType = DstType;
7616 break;
7617 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007618
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007619 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007620 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007621 if (Complained)
7622 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007623 return isInvalid;
7624}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007625
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007626bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007627 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7628 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7629 if (Result)
7630 *Result = ICEResult;
7631 return false;
7632 }
7633
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007634 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7635
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007636 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007637 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7638 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7639
7640 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7641 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7642 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7643 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7644 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7645 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7646 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007647
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007648 return true;
7649 }
7650
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007651 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7652 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007653
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007654 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7655 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7656 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007657
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007658 if (Result)
7659 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7660 return false;
7661}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007662
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007663void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007664Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007665 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7666 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007667}
7668
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007669void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007670Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7671 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7672 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7673 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007674
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007675 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7676 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7677 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7678 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7679 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007680 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007681 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7682 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7683 I != IEnd; ++I)
7684 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7685 }
7686
7687 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7688 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7689 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7690 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7691 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7692 I != IEnd; ++I)
7693 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7694 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007695 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007696
7697 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7698 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7699 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7700 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007701 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007702 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7703 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7704 ExprTemporaries.end());
7705
7706 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7707 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007708}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007709
7710/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7711///
7712/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7713/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7714/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7715/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7716///
7717/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7718///
7719/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7720void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7721 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007722
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007723 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007724 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007725
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007726 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7727 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7728 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7729 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007730 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007731 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007732 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007733 return;
7734 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007735
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007736 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7737 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007738
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007739 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7740 // an instantiation.
7741 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7742 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007743
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007744 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007745 case Unevaluated:
7746 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7747 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007748
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007749 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7750 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7751 // "used"; handle this below.
7752 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007753
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007754 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7755 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7756 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7757 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007758 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007759 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007760
7761 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7762 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7763 // containing expression is used.
7764 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007765 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007766
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007767 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007768 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007769 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007770 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007771 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7772 return;
7773 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7774 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007775 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007776 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007777 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007778 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7779 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007780
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007781 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007782 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007783 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007784 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007785 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7786 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007787 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7788 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7789 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007790 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007791 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007792 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7793 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007794 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007795 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007796 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007797 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007798 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007799 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7800 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7801 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7802 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7803 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007804 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007805 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007806 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007807 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007808 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7809 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7810 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007811 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007812 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007813 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7814 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007815
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007816 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7817 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7818 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7819 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7820 Loc));
7821 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007822 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007823 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007824 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7825 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7826 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007827 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007828 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7829 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007830
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007831 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007832
7833 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7834 if (CurContext != Function)
7835 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007836
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007837 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007838 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007839
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007840 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007841 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007842 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007843 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7844 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7845 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7846 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7847 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7848 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007849 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007850 }
7851 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007852
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007853 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007854
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007855 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007856 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007857 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007858}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007859
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007860namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007861 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007862 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007863 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007864 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7865 Sema &S;
7866 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007867
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007868 public:
7869 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007870
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007871 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007872
7873 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7874 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007875 };
7876}
7877
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007878bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7879 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007880 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7881 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7882 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007883
7884 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007885}
7886
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007887bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007888 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7889 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7890 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007891 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7892 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007893 }
7894
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007895 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007896}
7897
7898void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7899 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007900 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007901}
7902
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007903namespace {
7904 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7905 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7906 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7907 Sema &S;
7908
7909 public:
7910 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7911
7912 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7913
7914 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7915 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7916 }
7917
7918 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7919 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007920 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007921 }
7922
7923 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7924 if (E->getConstructor())
7925 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7926 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7927 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7928 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7929 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007930 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007931 }
7932
7933 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7934 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7935 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007936 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7937 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7938 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7939 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7940 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7941 }
7942
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007943 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007944 }
7945
7946 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7947 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007948 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007949 }
7950
7951 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7952 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7953 }
7954 };
7955}
7956
7957/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7958/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7959void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
7960 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
7961}
7962
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007963/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7964/// of the program being compiled.
7965///
7966/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007967/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007968/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7969/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7970/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7971/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007972/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007973/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007974///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007975/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7976/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7977/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7978/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007979bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007980 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7981 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7982 case Unevaluated:
7983 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7984 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007985
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007986 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007987 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007988 Diag(Loc, PD);
7989 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007990
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007991 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7992 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7993 break;
7994 }
7995
7996 return false;
7997}
7998
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007999bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8000 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8001 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8002 return false;
8003
8004 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8005 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8006 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8007 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008008
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008009 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008010 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008011 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8012 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008013 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008014 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8015 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8016 return true;
8017
8018 return false;
8019}
8020
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008021// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8022// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8023void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8024 SourceLocation Loc;
8025
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008026 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8027
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008028 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8029 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008030 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008031 return;
8032
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008033 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8034 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8035 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8036 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8037
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008038 // self = [<foo> init...]
8039 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8040 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8041 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8042
8043 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8044 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8045 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8046 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8047 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008048
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008049 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8050 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8051 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8052 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8053 return;
8054
8055 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8056 } else {
8057 // Not an assignment.
8058 return;
8059 }
8060
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008061 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008062 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008063
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008064 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008065 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008066 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008067 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8068 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8069 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008070}
8071
8072bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8073 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8074
8075 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008076 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008077
8078 QualType T = E->getType();
8079
8080 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8081 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8082 return true;
8083 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8084 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8085 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8086 return true;
8087 }
8088 }
8089
8090 return false;
8091}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008092
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008093ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8094 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008095 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008096 return ExprError();
8097
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008098 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008099 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008100
8101 return Owned(Sub);
8102}